blob: 6b3556cbaacbcf8f1bc17697a3c15c2c85f3c280 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000035#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000037#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000038using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000039using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000040
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000041
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000042/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
43/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
44///
45/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
46/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
47/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
48/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
49/// function is being used.
50///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
52/// decls.
53///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000054/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
55/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000056///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000059 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000060 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000061 }
62
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
64 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
67 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000068
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000069 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000070 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
72 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
73 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
74 return true;
75 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000076 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000077
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000079}
80
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000081/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000083/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
84///
85void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000087 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000090
91 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
92 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
94 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000096 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
97 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000098 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000099 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
100 int isMethod = 0;
101 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
102 // skip over named parameters.
103 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
104 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
105 if (nullPos)
106 --nullPos;
107 else
108 ++i;
109 }
110 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
111 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000113 // skip over named parameters.
114 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
115 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
116 if (nullPos)
117 --nullPos;
118 else
119 ++i;
120 }
121 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000122 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000123 // block or function pointer call.
124 QualType Ty = V->getType();
125 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000126 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000127 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
128 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000129 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
130 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
131 unsigned k;
132 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
133 if (nullPos)
134 --nullPos;
135 else
136 ++i;
137 }
138 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
139 }
140 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
141 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000142 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000143 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 return;
146
147 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 int sentinel = i;
153 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
154 --sentinelPos;
155 ++i;
156 }
157 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
158 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000159 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000160 return;
161 }
162 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
163 ++i;
164 ++sentinel;
165 }
166 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000167 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
168 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000170 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
172 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
173 return;
174
175 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
176 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
177
178 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
179 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000180}
181
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000182SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
183 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
184 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
185}
186
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
188// Standard Promotions and Conversions
189//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
192void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
193 QualType Ty = E->getType();
194 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
195
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000196 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000197 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000198 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000199 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
200 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
201 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
202 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
203 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
204 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
205 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000206 //
207 // C++ 4.2p1:
208 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
209 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
210 //
211 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
212 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000213 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000214 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000215 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000220
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221 QualType Ty = E->getType();
222 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
223 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
224 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
225 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
226 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
227 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
228 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
229 // rvalue is T
230 //
231 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000232 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
233 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000234 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000236 }
237}
238
239
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000240/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
243/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
244/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
245Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
246 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
247 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000249 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
250 //
251 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
252 // unsigned int may be used:
253 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
254 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
255 // and unsigned int.
256 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
257 //
258 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
259 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
260 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
261 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
263 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000264 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 return Expr;
266 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000268 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000269 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000271 }
272
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000273 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000274 return Expr;
275}
276
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000277/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000279/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
280void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
281 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
282 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000283
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000285 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
286 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000287 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000288
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000289 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
290}
291
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000292/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
293/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
294/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
295/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000296bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
297 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000299
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
301 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
302 // etc.
303 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
304 return false;
305
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000306 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000307 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
308 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
309 << Expr->getType() << CT))
310 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000311
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000312 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000313 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
315 << Expr->getType() << CT))
316 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000317
318 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000319}
320
321
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
323/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000324/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
326/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
327/// GCC.
328QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
329 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000330 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000331 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000332
333 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000334
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000335 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000336 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 QualType lhs =
338 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
342 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
343 if (lhs == rhs)
344 return lhs;
345
346 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
347 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
348 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
349 return lhs;
350
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000351 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
358
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000359 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000361 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
362 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363 return destType;
364}
365
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
367// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
369
370
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000371/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000372/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
373/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
374/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
375/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000376///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000377ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000378Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000379 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
380
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000381 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000382 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000383 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000384
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000385 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000386 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
387 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000390 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000391 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392
393 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000394 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000395 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000396
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000397 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
398 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
399 // strings.
400 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000401 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000402 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000403
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000404 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000405 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
406 Literal.GetStringLength(),
407 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
408 &StringTokLocs[0],
409 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000410}
411
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000412/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
413/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
414/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
415/// for values inside the block or for globals).
416///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000417/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000418/// up-to-date.
419///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000420static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000421 ValueDecl *VD) {
422 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
423 // we wanted to.
424 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
425 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000426
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000427 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
428 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
429 return false;
430
431 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
432 // snapshot it.
433 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
434 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
436 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000437
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000438 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
439 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
440
441 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
442 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
443 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
444 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
446 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000448 if (!NextBlock)
449 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000450
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000451 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
452 // having a reference outside it.
453 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
454 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000456 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
457 // a snapshot as well.
458 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
459 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462}
463
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000464
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000465ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000466Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000467 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000468 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
469 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
470}
471
472/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000473ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000474Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
475 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
476 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000479 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000480 << D->getDeclName();
481 return ExprError();
482 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000485 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
486 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
487 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000488 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000490 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
491 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000492 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
493 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000496 << D->getIdentifier();
497 return ExprError();
498 }
499 }
500 }
501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000503 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000505 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
506 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
507 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000509}
510
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000511/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
512/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
513/// actual member.
514///
515/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
516/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
517/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
518/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
519/// we found.
520///
521/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
522/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
523/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
524VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
525 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
527 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
528 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
529
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000530 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000531 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
532 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
533 do {
534 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000535 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000536 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 else {
539 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
540 break;
541 }
542 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000544 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545
546 return BaseObject;
547}
548
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000549ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000550Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
551 FieldDecl *Field,
552 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
553 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
554 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000555 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 AnonFields);
557
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
559 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
560 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
561 // found via name lookup.
562 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000563 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 if (BaseObject) {
565 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
566 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000567 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000568 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000569 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
573 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
574 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
575 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
576 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000577 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
579 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
580 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000581 BaseQuals
582 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000583 } else {
584 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
585 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
586 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000587 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
588 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000589 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 = Context.getTagDeclType(
592 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
593 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
596 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
597 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000599 MD->getThisType(Context),
600 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
602 }
603 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000604 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
605 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000606 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 }
609
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000610 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
614
615 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
616 // anonymous struct/union.
617 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000618 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
620 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
621 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
622 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000623 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
624 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
625
626 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
627 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
628 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
629 ResultQuals.removeConst();
630
631 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
632 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
633
634 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
635 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
636
637 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
638 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
639 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
640
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000641 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000642 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000643 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000644 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
645 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000646 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000647 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648 }
649
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000650 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000651}
652
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000653/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000654/// possibly a list of template arguments.
655///
656/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
657/// DecomposeTemplateName.
658///
659/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
660/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
661/// some way.
662static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
663 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
664 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000665 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000666 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
667 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
668 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
669 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
670
671 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
672 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
673 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
674 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
675 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
676
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000677 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000678 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
681 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000687/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
688/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
689/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
692 return false;
693
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
695 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
696 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
697 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
698 if (!BaseRT) return false;
699
700 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000701 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
703 return false;
704 }
705
706 return true;
707}
708
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000709/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
710/// the prospective base classes.
711static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
712 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
713 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000714 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000715 return false;
716
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000717 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (!RD) return false;
719 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
720
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
722 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
723 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
724 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
725 if (!BaseRT) return false;
726
727 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735enum IMAKind {
736 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
737 IMA_Static,
738
739 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
740 IMA_Mixed,
741
742 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
743 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
744 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
748 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
749
750 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Instance,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
754 IMA_Unresolved,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
757 /// context is not an instance method.
758 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
759
760 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
761 /// non-class context.
762 IMA_AnonymousMember,
763
764 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
765 /// context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
769 /// class.
770 IMA_Error_Unrelated
771};
772
773/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
774/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
775/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
776/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
777/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
778/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
779static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
780 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000781 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000784 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000785 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
786 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787
788 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
789 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
790
791 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
792 bool hasNonInstance = false;
793 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
794 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000795 NamedDecl *D = *I;
796 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
798
799 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
800 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
801 // that's a special case.
802 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
803 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
804 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
805 }
806 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
807 }
808 else
809 hasNonInstance = true;
810 }
811
812 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
813 // member reference.
814 if (Classes.empty())
815 return IMA_Static;
816
817 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
818 // an implicit member reference.
819 if (isStaticContext)
820 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
821
822 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
823 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
824 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
825 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000826 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 Classes))
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
829
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
831}
832
833/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
834static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
836 const LookupResult &R) {
837 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
838 SourceRange Range(Loc);
839 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
840
841 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
842 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
843 if (MD->isStatic()) {
844 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
845 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
846 << Range << R.getLookupName();
847 return;
848 }
849 }
850
851 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
852 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
853 return;
854 }
855
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000857}
858
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
860///
861/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000862bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
863 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
865
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
869 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000872 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
873 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000875 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
876 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
877 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
878 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000879 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
882 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
883
884 if (!R.empty()) {
885 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
886 R.suppressDiagnostics();
887
888 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
889 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
890 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
891 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
892
893 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
894 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
895 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000896 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
898 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000899 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000901 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000902 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
903 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
904 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
905 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
906 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
907 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
908 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
909 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
910 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
912 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
913 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
914 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
915 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000916 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000917 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
918 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
919 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000921 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000924
925 // Do we really want to note all of these?
926 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
927 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
928
929 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
930 return false;
931 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000932
933 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000934 }
935 }
936
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000937 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000938 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000939 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000940 if (!R.empty()) {
941 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
942 if (SS.isEmpty())
943 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
944 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
945 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
946 else
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
948 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
949 << SS.getRange()
950 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
951 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
952 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
953 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
954 << ND->getDeclName();
955
956 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
957 return false;
958 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000959
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
961 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
962 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
963 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
964 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
965 // to recover well anyway.
966 if (SS.isEmpty())
967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange();
972
973 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
974 return true;
975 }
976 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000977 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000978 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000979 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000980 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000981 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
984 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 return true;
986 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000988 }
989
990 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
991 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
992 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995 << SS.getRange();
996 return true;
997 }
998
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000999 // Give up, we can't recover.
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1001 return true;
1002}
1003
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001004static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001005 IdentifierInfo *II,
1006 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1008 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1009 if (!IDecl)
1010 return 0;
1011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1012 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1015 if (!property)
1016 return 0;
1017 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1018 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1019 return 0;
1020 return property;
1021}
1022
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001023static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001024 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001025 IdentifierInfo *II,
1026 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1027 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 bool LookForIvars;
1029 if (Lookup.empty())
1030 LookForIvars = true;
1031 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1032 LookForIvars = false;
1033 else
1034 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1035 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1036 if (!LookForIvars)
1037 return 0;
1038
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001039 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1040 if (!IDecl)
1041 return 0;
1042 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001043 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1044 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1046 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1047 if (!property)
1048 return 0;
1049 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1050 DynamicImplSeen =
1051 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1052 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001053 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1054 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001055 NameLoc,
1056 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1057 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1058 (Expr *)0, true);
1059 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1060 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1061 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1062 return Ivar;
1063 }
1064 return 0;
1065}
1066
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001067ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001068 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1069 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1070 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1071 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1073 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1074
1075 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001076 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001078 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079
1080 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001081 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001083 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001086 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001088
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1090 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001091 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1092 // (note: handled after lookup)
1093 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1094 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1095 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1097 // names a dependent type.
1098 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1099 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001100 bool DependentID = false;
1101 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1102 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1103 DependentID = true;
1104 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1105 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1106 if (DC) {
1107 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1108 return ExprError();
1109 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1110 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1111 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1112 } else {
1113 DependentID = true;
1114 }
1115 }
1116
1117 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 TemplateArgs);
1120 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001121 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001123 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001125 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1126 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1127 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1128 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1129 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001130 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1131 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1132 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001134 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001135 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1138 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001140 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 if (E.isInvalid())
1142 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1145 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001146 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1147 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001148 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001149 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1150 isAddressOfOperand);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001152 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1153 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001154 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001155 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001156
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1158 return ExprError();
1159
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001160 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1161 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001165 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1167 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1168 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1169 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1170 }
1171
1172 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1173 // call, diagnose the problem.
1174 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001175 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001176 return ExprError();
1177
1178 assert(!R.empty() &&
1179 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001180
1181 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1182 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001183 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1185 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001186 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1188 return move(E);
1189 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001190 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001191 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001192
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1194 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1195
1196 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001197 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001198 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1199 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001200 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1201 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1202 if (Property) {
1203 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1204 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001205 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001206 }
1207 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1210 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1211 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1212 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1213 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1214 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001217
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001218 QualType T = Func->getType();
1219 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001221 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1222 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001223 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001224 }
1225 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001226
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001227 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001228 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1229 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1230 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1231 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1232 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1233 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1234 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1235 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001236 //
1237 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1238 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1239 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1240 // non-static member function:
1241 //
1242 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1243 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1244 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1245 // member function call.
1246 //
1247 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1248 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1249 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1250 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001251 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001252 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1253 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1254 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1255 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1256 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1257 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001259 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001261 else
1262 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1263
1264 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001265 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001266 }
1267
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001268 if (TemplateArgs)
1269 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001270
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001271 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1272}
1273
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001274/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001275ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001276Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1277 LookupResult &R,
1278 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1279 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1280 case IMA_Instance:
1281 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1282
1283 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1284 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1285 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1286 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1287
1288 case IMA_Mixed:
1289 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1290 case IMA_Unresolved:
1291 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1292
1293 case IMA_Static:
1294 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1295 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1296 if (TemplateArgs)
1297 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1299
1300 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1301 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1302 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1303 return ExprError();
1304 }
1305
1306 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1307 return ExprError();
1308}
1309
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001310/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1311/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1312/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1313/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001314ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001315Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001316 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001317 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001318 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001319 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001320
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001321 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001322 return ExprError();
1323
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001324 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001325 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1326
1327 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1328 return ExprError();
1329
1330 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001331 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1332 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001333 return ExprError();
1334 }
1335
1336 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1337}
1338
1339/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1340/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1341/// additional lookup.
1342///
1343/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1344/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1345///
1346/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001347ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001349 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001350 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001351 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001352
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001353 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1354 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1355 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1356 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1357 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1358
1359 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1360 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1361 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001362 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001363
1364 bool LookForIvars;
1365 if (Lookup.empty())
1366 LookForIvars = true;
1367 else if (IsClassMethod)
1368 LookForIvars = false;
1369 else
1370 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1371 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001372 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001374 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1376 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1377 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1378 if (IsClassMethod)
1379 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1380 << IV->getDeclName());
1381
1382 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1383 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1384 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1385 return ExprError();
1386
1387 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1388 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1389 return ExprError();
1390
1391 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1392 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1393 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1394 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1395
1396 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1397 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1398 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1399 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001400 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001401 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001402 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001403 SelfName, false, false);
1404 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1405 return Owned(new (Context)
1406 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1407 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1408 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001409 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001410 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001411 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001412 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1413 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1414 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1415 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1416 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1417 }
1418 }
1419
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001420 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1421 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1422 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1423 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1424 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1425 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1426 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1427 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1428 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1429 }
1430 }
1431 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001432 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1433 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001434}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001435
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001436/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1437///
1438/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1439///
1440/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1441/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1442/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1443/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1444///
1445/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1446/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1447/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1448/// the class declaring the member.
1449///
1450/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1451/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1452/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001453bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001454Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1455 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001456 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001457 NamedDecl *Member) {
1458 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1459 if (!RD)
1460 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 QualType DestRecordType;
1463 QualType DestType;
1464 QualType FromRecordType;
1465 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1466 bool PointerConversions = false;
1467 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1468 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001469
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001470 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1471 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1472 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1473 PointerConversions = true;
1474 } else {
1475 DestType = DestRecordType;
1476 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001477 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1479 if (Method->isStatic())
1480 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001481
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001482 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1483 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001484
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1486 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1487 PointerConversions = true;
1488 } else {
1489 FromRecordType = FromType;
1490 DestType = DestRecordType;
1491 }
1492 } else {
1493 // No conversion necessary.
1494 return false;
1495 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001496
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001497 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1498 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001500 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1501 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1502 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1505 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1506
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001507 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001508
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001509 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 // class name.
1512 //
1513 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1514 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1515 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1516 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1517 //
1518 // class Base { public: int x; };
1519 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1520 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1521 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1522 //
1523 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1524 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1525 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1526 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001528 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1529 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1530 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1531
1532 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1533
1534 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1535 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1536 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1537 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001538 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001539 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001540 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001541 return true;
1542
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001543 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001544 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001545 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1546 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001547
1548 FromType = QType;
1549 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1550
1551 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1552 // we're done.
1553 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1554 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001555 }
1556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001557
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001559
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001560 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1561 // down to the using declaration's type.
1562 //
1563 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1564 // class ever has member declarations.
1565 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1566 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1567 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1568 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1569
1570 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1571 // conversion is non-trivial.
1572 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1573 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001574 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001575 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001576 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001578
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001579 QualType UType = URecordType;
1580 if (PointerConversions)
1581 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001582 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001583 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 FromType = UType;
1585 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1586 }
1587
1588 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1589 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1590 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001591 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001592
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001593 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001594 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1595 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001596 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001597 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001598
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001599 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001600 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001601 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001602}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001603
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001604/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001605static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001606 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001607 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001608 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1609 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001610 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1611 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1612 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001613 if (SS.isSet()) {
1614 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1615 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001616 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001617
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001618 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001619 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1620 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001621}
1622
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001623/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1624/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1625/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1626/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001627ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001628Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1629 LookupResult &R,
1630 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1631 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001632 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1633
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001634 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001635
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001636 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1637 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001638 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001640 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001641 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001642 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001643
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001644 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1645 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001646 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1647 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001648 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1649 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001650 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1651 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1652 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1653 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001654 }
1655
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001656 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001657 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1658 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001659 SS,
1660 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1661 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001662}
1663
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001664bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001665 const LookupResult &R,
1666 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001667 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1668 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1669 return false;
1670
1671 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001672 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001673 return false;
1674
1675 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001676 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001677 return false;
1678
1679 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1680 // normal lookup:
1681 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1682 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1683
1684 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1685 // -- a declaration of a class member
1686 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1687 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001688 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001689 return false;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1693 // using-declaration
1694 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1695 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1696 // turn off ADL anyway).
1697 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1698 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1699 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1700 return false;
1701
1702 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1703 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1704 // template
1705 // And also for builtin functions.
1706 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1707 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1708
1709 // But also builtin functions.
1710 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1711 return false;
1712 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1713 return false;
1714 }
1715
1716 return true;
1717}
1718
1719
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1721/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1722/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1723/// will in fact be used.
1724static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1725 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1726 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1727 return true;
1728 }
1729
1730 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1731 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1732 return true;
1733 }
1734
1735 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1736 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1737 return true;
1738 }
1739
1740 return false;
1741}
1742
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001743ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001744Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001745 LookupResult &R,
1746 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001747 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1748 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001749 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001750 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1751 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001752
1753 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1754 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1755 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001756 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1757 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001758 return ExprError();
1759
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001760 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1761 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1762 // we've picked a target.
1763 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1764
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001765 bool Dependent
1766 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001767 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001768 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001769 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001770 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001771 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1772 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773
1774 return Owned(ULE);
1775}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001776
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001777
1778/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001779ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001780Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001781 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1782 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001783 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001784 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1785 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001786
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001787 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001788 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1789 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001790
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001791 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1792 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1793 // a template argument list.
1794 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1795 << Template << SS.getRange();
1796 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1797 return ExprError();
1798 }
1799
1800 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1801 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1802 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001803 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001804 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001805 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001806 return ExprError();
1807 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001808
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001809 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1810 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1811 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1812 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001813 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001814 return ExprError();
1815
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001816 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1817 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818 return ExprError();
1819
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001820 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1821 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1822 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1823 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001824 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001825 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1826 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1827 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001828 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001829 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001830 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1831 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1832 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1833 return ExprError();
1834 }
1835
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001836 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1838 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1839 return ExprError();
1840 }
1841
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001842 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001843 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001844 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001845 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001846 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001847 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1848 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001849 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001851 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001852 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001853 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1854 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001855 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001856 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1857 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1858 Expr *E = new (Context)
1859 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1860 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001861
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001862 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001864 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001865 SourceLocation(),
1866 Owned(E));
1867 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001868 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001869 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1870 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1871 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001872 }
1873 }
1874 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001875 }
1876 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1877 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001878
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001879 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1880 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001881}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001882
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001883ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001884 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001885 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001886
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001887 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001888 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001889 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1890 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1891 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001892 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001893
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001894 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1895 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001896
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001897 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001898 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1899 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001900 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001901 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001902 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001903 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001904
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001905 QualType ResTy;
1906 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1907 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1908 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001909 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001911 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001912 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001913 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1914 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001915 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001916}
1917
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001918ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001919 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001920 bool Invalid = false;
1921 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1922 if (Invalid)
1923 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001924
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001925 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1926 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001927 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001928 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001929
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001930 QualType Ty;
1931 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1932 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1933 else if (Literal.isWide())
1934 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001935 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1936 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 else
1938 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001939
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001940 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1941 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001942 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001943}
1944
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001945ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001947 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1948 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001949 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001950 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001951 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001952 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001953 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001954
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001955 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001956 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1957 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001958 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001960 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001961 bool Invalid = false;
1962 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1963 if (Invalid)
1964 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001966 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001967 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001968 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001969 return ExprError();
1970
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001971 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001973 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001974 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001975 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001976 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001977 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001978 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001979 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001980 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001981
1982 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1983
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001984 using llvm::APFloat;
1985 APFloat Val(Format);
1986
1987 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001988
1989 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1990 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1991 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1992 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001993 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001994 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001995 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001996 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001997 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1998 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001999 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2001 }
2002
2003 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2004 << Ty
2005 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2006 }
2007
2008 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002009 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002010
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002011 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002012 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002013 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002014 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002015
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002016 // long long is a C99 feature.
2017 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002018 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002019 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2020
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002021 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002022 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002023
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002024 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2025 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002027 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2028 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002030 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2032 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002033
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002034 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2035 // be an unsigned int.
2036 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2037
2038 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002039 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002040 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2041 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002042 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002043
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002044 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2045 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2046 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2047 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002049 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002050 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002051 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002052 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002054
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002055 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002056 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002057 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002059 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2060 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2061 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2062 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002064 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002065 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002066 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002067 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068 }
2069
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002070 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002071 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002072 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002073
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2075 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2076 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2077 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002079 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002080 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002081 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002082 }
2083 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002084
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002085 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2086 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002088 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002089 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002090 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002091 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002092
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002093 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2094 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002095 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002096 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002097 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002099 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2100 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002101 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002102 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002103
2104 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002105}
2106
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002107ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002108 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002109 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002110 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002111}
2112
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002113/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002114/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002115bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2117 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2118 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002119 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2120 return false;
2121
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002122 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2123 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2124 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2125 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2126 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2127 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2128
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002129 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002130 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002131 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002132 if (isSizeof)
2133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2134 return false;
2135 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002136
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002137 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002138 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2140 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002145 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2146 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002147 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002149 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002150 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002152 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2153 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002154 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002156 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2158 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2159 return true;
2160 }
2161
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002162 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002163}
2164
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002165bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2166 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2167 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002168
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002169 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002170 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2171 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002172
2173 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2174 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2175 return false;
2176
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002177 if (E->getBitField()) {
2178 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2179 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002180 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002181
2182 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2183 // bit-field.
2184 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002185 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002186 return false;
2187
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002188 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2189}
2190
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002191/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002192ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002193Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002194 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002195 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002196 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002197 return ExprError();
2198
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002199 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002200
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002201 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2202 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2203 return ExprError();
2204
2205 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002206 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002207 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2208 R.getEnd()));
2209}
2210
2211/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2212/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002213ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002214Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002215 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2216 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2217 bool isInvalid = false;
2218 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2219 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2220 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2221 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002222 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002223 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2224 isInvalid = true;
2225 } else {
2226 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2227 }
2228
2229 if (isInvalid)
2230 return ExprError();
2231
2232 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2233 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2234 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2235 R.getEnd()));
2236}
2237
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002238/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2239/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2240/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002242Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2243 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002244 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002245 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002246
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002247 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002248 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002249 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002250 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002251 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002252
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002253 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002254 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002255 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2256
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002257 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002258}
2259
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002260QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002261 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2262 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002263
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002264 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002265 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002266 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002267
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002268 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2269 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2270 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002272 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2274 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002275 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002276}
2277
2278
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002279
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002280ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002281Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002282 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002283 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002284 switch (Kind) {
2285 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002286 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2287 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002288 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002289
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002290 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002291}
2292
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002293ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002294Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2295 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002296 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002297 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002298 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2299 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002300
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002301 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002302
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002303 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002304 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002305 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2306 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2307 }
2308
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002310 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002311 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2312 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2313 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002314 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002315 }
2316
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002317 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002318}
2319
2320
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002321ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002322Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2323 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2324 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2325 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002326
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002327 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002328 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2329 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2330 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002331
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002332 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002333
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002334 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002335 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002337 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002338 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2339 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002340 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2341 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2342 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2343 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002344 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002345 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2346 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002347 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002348 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002349 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002350 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2351 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002352 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002353 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002354 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002355 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2356 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2357 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002358 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002359 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002360 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2361 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2362 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2363 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002364 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002365 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002366 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002367
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002368 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2369 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002370 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2371 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002372 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002373 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2374 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2375 // force the promotion here.
2376 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2377 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002378 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002379 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002380 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2381
2382 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2383 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002384 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002385 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2386 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2387 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2388 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002389 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002390 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002391 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2392
2393 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2394 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002395 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002396 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002397 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2398 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002399 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002400 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002401 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002402 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2403 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002404
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002405 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002406 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2407 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002408 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2409
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002410 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002411 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2412 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002413 // incomplete types are not object types.
2414 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2415 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2416 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2417 return ExprError();
2418 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002419
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002420 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002422 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2423 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002424 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002425
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002426 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002427 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002428 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2429 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2430 return ExprError();
2431 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002432
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002433 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002434 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002435}
2436
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002437QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002438CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002439 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002440 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002441 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2442 // see FIXME there.
2443 //
2444 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2445 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002446 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002447
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002448 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002449 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002450
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002451 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002452 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2453 // to be selected.
2454 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002455
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002456 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2457 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002458 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002459
2460 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2461 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002462 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002463 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2464 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002465 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002466 do
2467 compStr++;
2468 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002469 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002470 do
2471 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002472 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002473 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002474
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002475 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002476 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2477 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002478 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002479 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002480 return QualType();
2481 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002482
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002483 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2484 // operates on.
2485 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002486 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002487
2488 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002489 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002490
2491 while (*compStr) {
2492 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2493 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2494 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2495 return QualType();
2496 }
2497 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002498 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002499
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002500 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002501 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002502 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002503 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002504 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002505 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002506 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002507 if (HexSwizzle)
2508 CompSize--;
2509
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002510 if (CompSize == 1)
2511 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002512
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002513 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002514 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002515 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2516 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2517 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2518 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002519 }
2520 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002521}
2522
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002523static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002524 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002525 const Selector &Sel,
2526 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002527
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002528 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002529 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002530 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002531 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002533 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2534 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002535 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002536 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002537 return D;
2538 }
2539 return 0;
2540}
2541
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002542static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002543 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002544 const Selector &Sel,
2545 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002546 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2547 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002548 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002549 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002550 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002551 GDecl = PD;
2552 break;
2553 }
2554 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002555 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002556 GDecl = OMD;
2557 break;
2558 }
2559 }
2560 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002561 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002562 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2563 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002564 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002565 if (GDecl)
2566 return GDecl;
2567 }
2568 }
2569 return GDecl;
2570}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002571
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002572ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002573Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002574 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002575 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2576 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002577 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002578 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002579 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2580 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2581 //
2582 // T* t;
2583 // t.f;
2584 //
2585 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2586 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2587 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2588 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002589 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2591 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002593 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002595 return ExprError();
2596 }
2597 }
2598
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002599 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2600 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002601 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002602
2603 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2604 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002605 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002607 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002608 SS.getRange(),
2609 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002610 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002611}
2612
2613/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2614/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2615/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2616static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2617 Expr *BaseExpr,
2618 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002619 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002620 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002621 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2622 // diagnostics.
2623 if (!BaseExpr)
2624 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002626 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2627 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628}
2629
2630// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2631// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2632// type. The restriction here is:
2633//
2634// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2635// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2636// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2637//
2638// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2639// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2640// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2641// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2642bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2643 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002644 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002645 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002646 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2647 if (!BaseRT) {
2648 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2649 // dependent.
2650 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2651 return false;
2652 }
2653 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002654
2655 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2657 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002658 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002660
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002661 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002662 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2663 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2664 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002665
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002666 if (!DC->isRecord())
2667 continue;
2668
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002670 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002671
2672 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2673 return false;
2674 }
2675
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002676 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002677 return true;
2678}
2679
2680static bool
2681LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2682 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002683 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2684 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002685 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2686 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002687 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 << BaseRange))
2689 return true;
2690
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002691 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2692 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2693 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2694
2695 bool MOUS;
2696 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2697 return false;
2698 }
2699
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002700 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2701 if (SS.isSet()) {
2702 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2703 // nested-name-specifier.
2704 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2705
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002706 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002707 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2708 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2709 return true;
2710 }
2711
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002712 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002713
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002714 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2715 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2716 << DC << SS.getRange();
2717 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002718 }
2719 }
2720
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002721 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2722 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002723
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002724 if (!R.empty())
2725 return false;
2726
2727 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2728 // for typos.
2729 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002730 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002731 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002732 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2733 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2734 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002735 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2736 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002737 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2738 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2739 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002740 return false;
2741 } else {
2742 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002743 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002744 }
2745
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746 return false;
2747}
2748
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002749ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002750Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002751 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002752 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002753 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002754 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002756 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2757 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002758 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2760 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002761 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002762
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002763 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 // Implicit member accesses.
2766 if (!Base) {
2767 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2768 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2769 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2770 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002771 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002772 return ExprError();
2773
2774 // Explicit member accesses.
2775 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002776 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002777 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002778 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779
2780 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2781 Owned(Base);
2782 return ExprError();
2783 }
2784
2785 if (Result.get())
2786 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002787
2788 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2789 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790 }
2791
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002792 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002793 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2794 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795}
2796
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002797ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002798Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002799 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2800 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002801 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002802 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002803 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2804 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002805 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806 if (IsArrow) {
2807 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2808 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2809 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002810 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002812 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002813 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2814 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2815 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816
2817 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002818 return ExprError();
2819
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 if (R.empty()) {
2821 // Rederive where we looked up.
2822 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2823 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2824 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002825
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002827 << MemberName << DC
2828 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829 return ExprError();
2830 }
2831
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002832 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2833 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2834 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2835 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2836 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2837 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2838 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2839 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2840 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2841 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002842 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002843 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002844 return ExprError();
2845
2846 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2847 // result.
2848 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002849 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002850 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002851 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002852 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002854 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2855 // pick a member.
2856 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2857
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2859 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2860 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002861 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2862 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002864 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002865 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866
2867 return Owned(MemExpr);
2868 }
2869
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002870 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002871 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2873
2874 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2875
2876 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2877 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2878 // error cases.
2879 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2880 return ExprError();
2881
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002882 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2883 if (!BaseExpr) {
2884 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002885 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002886 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002887
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002888 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2889 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2890 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2891 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002892 }
2893
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002894 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2895 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2896 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2897 // explicitly qualified.
2898 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2899 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2900 }
2901
2902 // Check the use of this member.
2903 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2904 Owned(BaseExpr);
2905 return ExprError();
2906 }
2907
2908 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2909 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2910 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002911 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2912 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002913 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2914 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2915
2916 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2917 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2918 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2919 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2920 else {
2921 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2922 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2923 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2924
2925 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2926 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2927
2928 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2929 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2930 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2931 }
2932
2933 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002934 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002935 return ExprError();
2936 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002937 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2938 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002939 }
2940
2941 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2942 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2943 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002944 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2946 }
2947
2948 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2949 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2950 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002951 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002952 MemberFn->getType()));
2953 }
2954
2955 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2956 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2957 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002958 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2959 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002960 }
2961
2962 Owned(BaseExpr);
2963
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002964 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002965 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002966 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002967 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2968 else
2969 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2970 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002972 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2973 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002974 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002975 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002976}
2977
2978/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2979/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2980/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2981/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2982/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2983/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2984/// an ordinary member expression.
2985///
2986/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2987/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002988ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002989Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002990 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002991 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002992 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002993 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002994
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002995 // Perform default conversions.
2996 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002997
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002998 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002999 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3000
3001 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3002 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003003
3004 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003005 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003006 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3007 // call, and continue on.
3008 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3009 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3010 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3011 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3012 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3014 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003015 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3016 ->isRecordType()))) {
3017 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3018 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3019 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003020 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003021
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003022 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003023 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003024 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003025 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003026 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003027
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003028 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3029 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3030 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3031 }
3032 }
3033 }
3034
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003035 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3036 // use that.
3037 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003038 if (IsArrow) {
3039 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3040 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3041 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003042 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003043 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003044 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3045 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003046 }
3047 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003048 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3049 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3050 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3051 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003052 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003053 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003054 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003055
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003056 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3057 // use that.
3058 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3059 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3060 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3061 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3062 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003063 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003064 }
3065 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003067 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003068
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003069 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003070 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003071 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3072 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3073 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3074 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3075 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3076 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3077 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3078 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3079 // Check the use of this method.
3080 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3081 return ExprError();
3082 }
3083 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3084 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3085 Selector SetterSel =
3086 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3087 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3088 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3089 if (!Setter) {
3090 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3091 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003092 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003093 }
3094 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3095 if (!Setter)
3096 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003097
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003098 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3099 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003100
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003101 if (Getter || Setter) {
3102 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003103
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003104 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003105 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 else
3107 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3108 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3109 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003110 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003111 PType,
3112 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3113 }
3114 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3115 << MemberName << BaseType);
3116 }
3117 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003118
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003119 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3120 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3121 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003122 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003123 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003125 if (IsArrow) {
3126 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003127 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003128 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3129 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003130 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3131 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3132 // struct MyRecord foo;
3133 // foo->bar
3134 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3135 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3136 // by now.
3137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3138 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003139 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003140 IsArrow = false;
3141 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003142 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3143 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3144 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003145 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003146 } else {
3147 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3148 // type *foo;
3149 // foo.bar
3150 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3151 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3152 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3153 // the appropriate pointer type
3154 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3155 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3156 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3158 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003159 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003160 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3161 IsArrow = true;
3162 }
3163 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003164 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003165
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003166 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003167 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003168 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003169 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003170 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003171 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003172 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003173
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003174 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3175 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003176 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003177 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003178 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003179 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3180 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3181 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3182 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003183 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3184
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003185 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003186 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003187
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003188 if (!IV) {
3189 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3190 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3191 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003192 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003193 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003194 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003195 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3196 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003197 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3198 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003199 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003200 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003201 } else {
3202 Res.clear();
3203 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003204 }
3205 }
3206
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003207 if (IV) {
3208 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3209 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3210 // error cases.
3211 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3212 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003213
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003214 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3216 return ExprError();
3217 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3218 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3219 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3220 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3221 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3222 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3223 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3224 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3225 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3226 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3227 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3228 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003229 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003230 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003231 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3232 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003233 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003234 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3235 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003236
3237 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3238 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003239 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003241 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003242 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3243 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003244 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003246 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003247
3248 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3249 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003250 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003251 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003253 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003254 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003255 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003256 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003257 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003258 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3259 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003260 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003261 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003262
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003263 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003264 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003265 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3266 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3267 // Check the use of this declaration
3268 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3269 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003270
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003271 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3272 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3273 }
3274 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3275 // Check the use of this method.
3276 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3277 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003278
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003279 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003280 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003281 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3282 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003283 }
3284 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003285
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003286 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003287 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003288 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003289
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003290 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3291 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003292 if (!IsArrow)
3293 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3294 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003295 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003296
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003297 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003299 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3300 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003302 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003303 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003304
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003305 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003306 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003307 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003308 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3309 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003310 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003311 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003312 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003313 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003314
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003315 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3316 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3317
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003318 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003319}
3320
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003321/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3322/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3323/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3324/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3325/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3326///
3327/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3328/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3329/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3330/// only be called
3331/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3332/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3333/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003334ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003335 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3336 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003337 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003338 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003339 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3341 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3342 return ExprError();
3343
3344 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3345
3346 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003347 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003348 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3349 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003350 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003351
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003352 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3354
3355 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3356 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3357 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3358
3359 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003360 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003361 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3362 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003363
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003364 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3365 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003366 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3368 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003369 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003371 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003372 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3373 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003374
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003375 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3376 Owned(Base);
3377 return ExprError();
3378 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003379
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003380 if (Result.get()) {
3381 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3382 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3383 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3384 // call now.
3385 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3386 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003387 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003388
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003389 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003390 }
3391
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003392 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003393 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3394 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003395 }
3396
3397 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003398}
3399
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003400ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003401 FunctionDecl *FD,
3402 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3403 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3404 Diag (CallLoc,
3405 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3406 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003407 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003408 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3409 } else {
3410 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3411 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3412
3413 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003414 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3415 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003416
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003417 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3418 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3419 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3420 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003421
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003422 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003423 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003424 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003425
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003426 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3427 InitializedEntity Entity
3428 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3429 InitializationKind Kind
3430 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3431 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3432 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3433
3434 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003435 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003436 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003437 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003438 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003439
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003440 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003441 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003442 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003443 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003444
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003445 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3446 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3447 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003448 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3449 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003450 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3451 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003452 }
3453
3454 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003455 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003456}
3457
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003458/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3459/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3460/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3461/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3462/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3463/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003464bool
3465Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003467 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3469 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003470 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003471 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3472 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003473 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003474
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003475 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3476 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3477 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3478 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3479 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003480 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003481 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003482 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003483 }
3484
3485 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3486 // them.
3487 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3488 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3489 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3490 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003491 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003492 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3494 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3495 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003496 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003497 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003498 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003499 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003500 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003501 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003502 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3503 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3504 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3505 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3506 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003507 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003508 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003509 if (Invalid)
3510 return true;
3511 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3512 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3513 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003514
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003515 return false;
3516}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003517
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003518bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3519 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3520 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3521 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3522 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3523 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003524 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003525 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3526 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3527 bool Invalid = false;
3528 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3529 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3530 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3531 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003532 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003533 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003534 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003535
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003536 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003537 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3538 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003539
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003540 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3541 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003542 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003543 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003544 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003545
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003546 // Pass the argument
3547 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3548 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3549 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003550
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003551
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003552 InitializedEntity Entity =
3553 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3554 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003555 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003556 SourceLocation(),
3557 Owned(Arg));
3558 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3559 return true;
3560
3561 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003562 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003563 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003565 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003566 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003567 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3568 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003569
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003570 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003571 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003572 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003573 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003574
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003575 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003576 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003577 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003578 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003579 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003580 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003581 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003582 }
3583 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003584 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003585}
3586
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003587/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003588/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3589/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003590ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003591Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003592 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003593 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003594
3595 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003596 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003597 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3598 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003599
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003600 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003601
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003602 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003603 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3604 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3605 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3606 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3607 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003608 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003609 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3610 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003611
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003612 NumArgs = 0;
3613 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003614
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003615 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3616 RParenLoc));
3617 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003618
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003619 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003620 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003621 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3622 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003623 bool Dependent = false;
3624 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3625 Dependent = true;
3626 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3627 Dependent = true;
3628
3629 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003630 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003631 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3632
3633 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3634 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3635 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003636 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003637
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003638 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3639
3640 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3641 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3642 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3643 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3644 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3645 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3646 // method template.
3647 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003648 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3649 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003650 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003651
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003652 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003653 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003654 }
3655
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003656 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003657 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003658 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003659 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003660 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003661 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003662 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003663
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003664 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003665 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003666 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3667 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003668 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3669 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003670 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003671
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003672 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3673 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3674 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3675 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003676
3677 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3678 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003679 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003680 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003681
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003682 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003683 RParenLoc))
3684 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003685
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003686 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003688 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003689 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3690 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003691 }
3692 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003693 }
3694
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003695 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003696 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003697 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003698
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003699 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003700 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3701 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003702 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003703 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003704 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003705
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003706 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3707 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3708 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3709
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003710 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3711}
3712
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003713/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3714/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003715/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3716/// block-pointer type.
3717///
3718/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003719ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003720Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3721 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3722 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3723 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3724 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3725
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003726 // Promote the function operand.
3727 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3728
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003729 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3730 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003731 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3732 Args, NumArgs,
3733 Context.BoolTy,
3734 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003735
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003736 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3737 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3738 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3739 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003740 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003741 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003742 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3743 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003744 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003745 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003746 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003747 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003748 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003749 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003750 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3751 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3752
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003753 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003754 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003755 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003756 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003757 return ExprError();
3758
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003759 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003760 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003761
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003762 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003763 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003764 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003765 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003766 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003767 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003768
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003769 if (FDecl) {
3770 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3771 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3772 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003773 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003774 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003775 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003776 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3777 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3778 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3779 }
3780 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003781 }
3782
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003783 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003784 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3785 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3786 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003787 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3788 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003789 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3790 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003791 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003792 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003793 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003794 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003795
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003796 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3797 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003798 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3799 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003800
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003801 // Check for sentinels
3802 if (NDecl)
3803 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003804
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003805 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003806 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003807 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003808 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003809
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003810 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003811 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003812 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003813 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003814 return ExprError();
3815 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003816
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003817 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003818}
3819
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003820ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003821Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003822 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003823 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003824 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003825 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003826
3827 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3828 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3829 if (!TInfo)
3830 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3831
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003832 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003833}
3834
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003835ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003836Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003837 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003838 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003839
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003840 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003841 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003842 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3843 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003844 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3845 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003846 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003847 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003848 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003849 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003850
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003851 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003852 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003853 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003854 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003855 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003856 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003857 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003858 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003859 &literalType);
3860 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003861 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003862 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003863
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003864 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003865 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003866 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003867 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003868 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003869
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003870 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003871 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003872}
3873
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003874ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003875Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003876 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3877 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003878 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003879
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003880 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003881 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003882
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003883 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3884 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003885 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003886 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003887}
3888
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003889static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003890 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003891 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003892 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003893
3894 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3895 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003896 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003897 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3898 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003899 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003900 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003901 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003902
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003903 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3904 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003905 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003907 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003908 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003909 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003910 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003911
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003912 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3913 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003914 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003915 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003916 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003917 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003918
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003919 // FIXME: Assert here.
3920 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922}
3923
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003924/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003925bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003927 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003928 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003929 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003930 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3931 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003932
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003933 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003934
3935 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3936 // type needs to be scalar.
3937 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3938 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003939 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003940 return false;
3941 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003942
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003943 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3944 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3945 return true;
3946
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003947 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003948 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003949 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3950 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003951 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003952 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3953 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003954 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003955 return false;
3956 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003957
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003958 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003959 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003960 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003961 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003962 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003963 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003964 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003965 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003966 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3967 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3968 break;
3969 }
3970 }
3971 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3972 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3973 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003974 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003975 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003976 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003978 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3979 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3980 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3981 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003982
3983 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003984 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003985 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3986 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003987 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003988 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003989
3990 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003991 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003992
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003993 if (castType->isVectorType())
3994 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3995 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3996 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3997
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003998 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3999 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004000
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004001 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004002 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004003 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004004 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004005 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4006 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4007 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4008 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004009 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004010 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4011 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4012 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004013 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004014
4015 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004016
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004017 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004018 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4019
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004020 return false;
4021}
4022
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004023bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004024 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004025 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004026
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004027 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004028 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004029 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004030 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004031 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004032 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004033 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004034 } else
4035 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004036 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004037 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004038
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004039 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004040 return false;
4041}
4042
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004043bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004044 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004045 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004046
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004047 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004048
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004049 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4050 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004051 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4052 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4053 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4054 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004055 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004056 return false;
4057 }
4058
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004059 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004060 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4061 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004062 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4063 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4064 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4065 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004066
4067 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4068 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4069 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004070
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004071 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004072 return false;
4073}
4074
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004075ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004076Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004077 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4078 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004079 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004080
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004081 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4082 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4083 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004084 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004085
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004086 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4087 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004088 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004089 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004090
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004091 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004092}
4093
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004094ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004095Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004096 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004097 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004098 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004099 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004100 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004101 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004102
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004103 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004104 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004105 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4106 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004107}
4108
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004109/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4110/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004111ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004112Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4114 if (!E)
4115 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004116
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004117 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004118
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004119 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004120 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4121 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004122
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004123 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4124
4125 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004126}
4127
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004128ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004130 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004131 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004132 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004133 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004134 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004135
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004136 // Check for an altivec literal,
4137 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004138 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4139 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4140 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4141 return ExprError();
4142 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004143 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4144 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4145 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4146 }
4147 else
4148 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4149 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004150
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004151 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4152 // then handle it as such.
4153 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4155 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4156 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4157
4158 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4159 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004160 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4161 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004162 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4163 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004164 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004165 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004166 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004168 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004169 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4170 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004171 }
4172}
4173
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004174ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004175 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004176 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004177 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004178 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4179 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004180 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4181 Expr *expr;
4182 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4183 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4184 else
4185 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004186 return Owned(expr);
4187}
4188
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004189/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4190/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004191/// C99 6.5.15
4192QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4193 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004194 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4195 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4196 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4197
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004198 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4199 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4200 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4201 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4202 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4203 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004204
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004205 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004206 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4207 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4208 << CondTy;
4209 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004210 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004211
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004212 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004213 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4214 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004215
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004216 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4217 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004218 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4219 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4220 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004221 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004222
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004223 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4224 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004225 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4226 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004227 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004228 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004229 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004230 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004231 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004232 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004233
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004234 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004235 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004236 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4237 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4238 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4239 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4240 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4241 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4242 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004243 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4244 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004245 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004246 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004247 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4248 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004249 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004250 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004251 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004252 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004253 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004254 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004255 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004256 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004257 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004258 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004259 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004260
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004261 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4262 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4263 QuestionLoc);
4264 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4265 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004266
4267
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004268 // Handle block pointer types.
4269 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4270 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4271 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4272 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004275 return destType;
4276 }
4277 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004278 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004279 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004280 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004281 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4282 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4283 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004284 return LHSTy;
4285 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004286 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004287 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4288 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004289
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004290 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4291 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004292 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004293 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004294 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4295 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4296 // to get a consistent AST.
4297 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004298 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4299 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004300 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004301 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004302 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004303 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4304 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004305 return LHSTy;
4306 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004307
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004308 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4309 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4310 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004311 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4312 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004313
4314 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4315 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4316 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004317 QualType destPointee
4318 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004319 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004320 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004321 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004322 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004323 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004324 return destType;
4325 }
4326 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004327 QualType destPointee
4328 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004329 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004330 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004331 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004332 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004333 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 return destType;
4335 }
4336
4337 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4338 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4339 return LHSTy;
4340 }
4341 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4342 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4343 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4344 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4345 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4346 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4347 // to get a consistent AST.
4348 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004349 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4350 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return incompatTy;
4352 }
4353 // The pointer types are compatible.
4354 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4355 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4356 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4357 // type.
4358 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4359 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004360 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4361 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004362 return LHSTy;
4363 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004364
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004365 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4366 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4367 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4368 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004369 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004370 return RHSTy;
4371 }
4372 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4373 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4374 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004375 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004376 return LHSTy;
4377 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004378
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004379 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004380 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4381 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004382 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004383}
4384
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004385/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4386/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4387QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4388 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4389 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4390 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004391
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004392 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4393 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4394 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4395 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4396 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004397 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004398 return LHSTy;
4399 }
4400 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4401 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004402 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004403 return RHSTy;
4404 }
4405 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4406 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4407 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004408 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004409 return LHSTy;
4410 }
4411 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4412 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004413 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004414 return RHSTy;
4415 }
4416 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4417 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4418 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004419 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004420 return LHSTy;
4421 }
4422 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4423 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004424 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004425 return RHSTy;
4426 }
4427 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4428 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004429
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004430 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4431 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4432 return LHSTy;
4433 }
4434 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4435 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4436 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004437
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004438 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4439 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4440 // type. This allows
4441 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4442 // where B is a subclass of A.
4443 //
4444 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4445 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4446 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4447 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004448
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004449 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4450 // It could return the composite type.
4451 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4452 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4453 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4454 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4455 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4456 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4457 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4458 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4459 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4460 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4461 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4462 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4463 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4464 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004465 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004466 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4467 ;
4468 else {
4469 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4470 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4471 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4472 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004473 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4474 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004475 return incompatTy;
4476 }
4477 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004478 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4479 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004480 return compositeType;
4481 }
4482 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4483 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4484 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4485 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4486 QualType destPointee
4487 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4488 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4489 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004490 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004491 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004492 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004493 return destType;
4494 }
4495 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4496 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4497 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4498 QualType destPointee
4499 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4500 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4501 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004502 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004503 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004504 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004505 return destType;
4506 }
4507 return QualType();
4508}
4509
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004510/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004511/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004512ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004513 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004514 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4515 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004516 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4517 // was the condition.
4518 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004519 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4520 if (isLHSNull) {
4521 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4522 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004523
4524 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004525 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004526 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004527 return ExprError();
4528
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004529 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004530 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4531 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4532 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004533}
4534
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004535// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004536// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004537// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4538// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4539// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004540Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004541Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004542 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004543
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004544 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4545 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4546 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4547 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4548 return Compatible;
4549 }
4550
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004551 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004552 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4553 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004554
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004555 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004556 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4557 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004558
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004559 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004560
4561 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4562 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4563 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004564 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004565 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004566 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004567
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004568 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4569 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004570 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004571 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004572 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004573 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004574
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004575 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004576 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4577 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004578 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004579
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004580 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004581 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004582 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004583
4584 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004585 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4586 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004587 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004588 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004589 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004590 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4591 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4592 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4593 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4594 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4595 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004596 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004597 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004598 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004599 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004600
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004601 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004602 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004603 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004604 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004605
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4607 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4608 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4609 // warning can be disabled.
4610 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4611 return ConvTy;
4612 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4613 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004614
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004615 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4616 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4617 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4618 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4619 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4620 do {
4621 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4622 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004623
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004624 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4625 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4626 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004627
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004628 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004629 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004630 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004631
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004632 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004633 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004634 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004635 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004636}
4637
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004638/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4639/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4640/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4641// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004642Sema::AssignConvertType
4643Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004644 QualType rhsType) {
4645 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004646
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004647 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004648 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4649 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004651 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4652 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4653 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004654
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004655 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004656
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004657 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004658 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004659 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004660
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004661 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4662 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4663 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4664 }
4665 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004666 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004667 return ConvTy;
4668}
4669
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004670/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4671/// for assignment compatibility.
4672Sema::AssignConvertType
4673Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004674 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4675 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004676 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4677 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004678 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004679 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004680 }
4681 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4682 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004683 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4684 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004685 return IncompatiblePointer;
4686 return Compatible;
4687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004688 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004689 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004690 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004691 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4692 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4693 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4694 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4695 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4696 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004697
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004698 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4699 return Compatible;
4700 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4701 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004702 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004703}
4704
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004705/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4706/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004707/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4708///
4709/// int a, *pint;
4710/// short *pshort;
4711/// struct foo *pfoo;
4712///
4713/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4714/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4715/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4716/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4717///
4718/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004719/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004720///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004721Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004722Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004723 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4724 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004725 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4726 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004727
4728 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004729 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004730
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004731 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4732 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4733 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4734 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4735 return Compatible;
4736 }
4737
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004738 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4739 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4740 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4741 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4742 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4743 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4744 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004745 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004746 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004747 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004748 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004749 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004750 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4751 // to the same ExtVector type.
4752 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4753 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4754 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004755 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004756 return Compatible;
4757 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004758
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004759 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004760 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4761 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4762 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4763 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4764 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4765 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004766 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004767
4768 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4769 // vector type and vice versa
4770 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4771 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004772 }
4773 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004774 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004775
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004776 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4777 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004778 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004779
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004780 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004781 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004782 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004783
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004784 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004785 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004786
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004787 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004788 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004789 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4790 return Compatible;
4791 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004792 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004793 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4794 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004795 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004796
4797 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004798 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004799 return Compatible;
4800 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004801 return Incompatible;
4802 }
4803
4804 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4805 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004806 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004807
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004808 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004809 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004810 return Compatible;
4811
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004812 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4813 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004814
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004815 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004816 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004817 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004818 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004819 return Incompatible;
4820 }
4821
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004822 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4823 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4824 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004825
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004826 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004827 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004828 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4829 return Compatible;
4830 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004831 }
4832 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004833 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004834 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004835 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004836 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4837 return Compatible;
4838 }
4839 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4840 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4841 return Compatible;
4842 return Incompatible;
4843 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004844 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004845 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004846 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4847 return Compatible;
4848
4849 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004850 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004851
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004852 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004853 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004854
4855 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004856 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004857 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004858 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004859 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004860 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4861 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4862 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4863 return Compatible;
4864
4865 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4866 return PointerToInt;
4867
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004868 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004869 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004870 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4871 return Compatible;
4872 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004873 }
4874 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004875 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004876 return Compatible;
4877 return Incompatible;
4878 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004879
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004880 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004881 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004882 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004883 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004884 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004885}
4886
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004887/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4888/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004889static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004890 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4891 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4892 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004893 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004894 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004895 SourceLocation());
4896 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4897 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4898
4899 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4900 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004901 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004902 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004903 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004904}
4905
4906Sema::AssignConvertType
4907Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4908 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4909
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004910 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004911 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4912 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004913 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004914 return Incompatible;
4915
4916 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4917 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4918 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4919 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004920 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4921 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004922 it != itend; ++it) {
4923 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4924 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4925 // 1) void pointer
4926 // 2) null pointer constant
4927 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004928 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004929 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004930 InitField = *it;
4931 break;
4932 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004933
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004934 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004935 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004936 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004937 InitField = *it;
4938 break;
4939 }
4940 }
4941
4942 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4943 == Compatible) {
4944 InitField = *it;
4945 break;
4946 }
4947 }
4948
4949 if (!InitField)
4950 return Incompatible;
4951
4952 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4953 return Compatible;
4954}
4955
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004956Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004957Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004958 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4959 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4960 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4961 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4962 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004963 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004964 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004965 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004966 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004967 }
4968
4969 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4970 // structures.
4971 }
4972
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004973 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4974 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004975 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4976 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004977 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004978 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004979 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004980 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004981 return Compatible;
4982 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004984 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004985 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004986 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004987 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004988 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004989 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004990 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004991 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004992
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004993 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4994 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004996 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4997 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004998 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4999 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5000 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5001 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005002 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005003 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005004 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005005 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005006}
5007
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005008QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005009 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005010 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005011 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005012 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005013}
5014
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005015QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005016 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005017 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005018 QualType lhsType =
5019 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5020 QualType rhsType =
5021 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005022
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005023 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005024 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005025 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005026
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005027 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5028 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005029 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005030 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005031 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005032 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005033 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005034 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005035 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005036 return lhsType;
5037 }
5038
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005039 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005040 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005041 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5042 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5043 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5044 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5045 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5046 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005047 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005048 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005049 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005050 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005051
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005052 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5053 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5054 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005055 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005056 return rhsType;
5057 }
5058
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005059 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5060 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5061 bool swapped = false;
5062 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5063 swapped = true;
5064 std::swap(rex, lex);
5065 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5066 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005067
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005068 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005069 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005070 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005071 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005072 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005073 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005074 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5075 return lhsType;
5076 }
5077 }
5078 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5079 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5080 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005081 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005082 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5083 return lhsType;
5084 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005085 }
5086 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005087
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005088 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005089 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005090 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005091 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005092 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005093}
5094
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005095QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5096 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005097 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005098 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005099
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005100 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005101
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005102 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5103 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5104 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005105
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005106 // Check for division by zero.
5107 if (isDiv &&
5108 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005109 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005110 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005111
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005112 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005113}
5114
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005115QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005116 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005117 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005118 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5119 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005120 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5121 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5122 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005123
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005124 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005125
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005126 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5127 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005128
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005129 // Check for remainder by zero.
5130 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005131 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5132 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005133
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005134 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005135}
5136
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005137QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005138 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005139 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5140 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5141 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5142 return compType;
5143 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005144
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005145 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005146
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005147 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005148 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5149 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5150 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005151 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005152 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005153
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005154 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5155 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005156 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005157 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5158
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005159 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005160
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005161 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005162 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005163
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005164 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5165 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005166 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5167 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005168 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005169 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005170 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005171
5172 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5173 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5174 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005175 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005176 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5177 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5178 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5179 return QualType();
5180 }
5181
5182 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5183 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5184 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005185 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005186 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005187 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005188 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005189 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5190 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005191 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5192 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005193 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005194 return QualType();
5195 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005196 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005197 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005198 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5199 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5200 return QualType();
5201 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005202
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005203 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005204 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5205 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5206 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5207 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5208 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005209 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005210 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5211 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005212 return PExp->getType();
5213 }
5214 }
5215
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005216 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005217}
5218
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005219// C99 6.5.6
5220QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005221 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5222 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5223 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5224 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5225 return compType;
5226 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005227
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005228 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005229
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005230 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005231
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005232 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005233 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5234 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005235 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005236 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005240 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005241 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005242
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005243 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005244
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005245 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5246 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5247 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5248 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5249 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5250 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5251 return QualType();
5252 }
5253
5254 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5255 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5256 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5257 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5258 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005259 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005260 return QualType();
5261 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005262
5263 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5264 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5265 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005266 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005267 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005268 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005269 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005270 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005271
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005272 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005273 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005274 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5275 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5276 return QualType();
5277 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005278
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005279 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005280 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5281 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5282 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5283 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5284 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5285 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005286 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005287 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5288
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005289 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005290 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005291 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005292
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005293 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005294 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005295 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005296
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005297 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5298 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5299 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5300 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5301 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5302 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5303 return QualType();
5304 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005305
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005306 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5307 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5308 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005310 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005311 return QualType();
5312 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005313
5314 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5315 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5316 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5317 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5318 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005319 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5320 << rex->getSourceRange()
5321 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005322 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005323
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005324 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5325 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5326 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5327 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5328 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5329 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5330 return QualType();
5331 }
5332 } else {
5333 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5334 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5335 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5336 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5337 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5338 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5339 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5340 return QualType();
5341 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005342 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005343
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005344 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5345 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5346 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5347 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5348 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005349 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005350 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005351
5352 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005353 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5354 }
5355 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005357 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005358}
5359
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005360// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005361QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005362 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005363 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005364 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5365 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005366 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005367
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005368 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5369 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5370 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5371
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005372 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5373 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005374 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5375 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5376 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5377 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5378 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005379 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005380 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005381 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005382
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005383 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005384
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005385 // Sanity-check shift operands
5386 llvm::APSInt Right;
5387 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005388 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5389 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005390 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005391 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5392 else {
5393 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5394 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5395 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5396 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5397 }
5398 }
5399
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005400 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005401 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005402}
5403
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005404static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5405 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5406 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5407 return true;
5408 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5409 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5410 }
5411 return false;
5412}
5413
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005414// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005415QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005416 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005417 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005418
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005419 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005420 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005421 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005422
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005423 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5424 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005425
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005426 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5427 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005428 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5429 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5430 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005431 //
5432 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5433 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5434 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5435 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5436 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5437 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005438 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5439 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005440 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005441 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005442 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005443 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005444 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5445 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005446 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5447 || Opc == BO_LE
5448 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005449 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5450 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5451 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5452 // what is it always going to eval to?
5453 char always_evals_to;
5454 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005455 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005456 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5457 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005458 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005459 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5460 break;
5461 default:
5462 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5463 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5464 break;
5465 }
5466 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5467 << 1 // array
5468 << always_evals_to);
5469 }
5470 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005473 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5474 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5475 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5476 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005477
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005478 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5479 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005480 Expr *literalString = 0;
5481 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005482 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005483 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005484 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005485 literalString = lex;
5486 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005487 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5488 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005489 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005490 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005491 literalString = rex;
5492 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5493 }
5494
5495 if (literalString) {
5496 std::string resultComparison;
5497 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005498 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5499 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5500 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5501 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5502 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5503 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005504 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5505 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005506
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005507 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5508 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5509 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005510 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005511 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005512 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005513
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005514 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5515 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5516 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5517 else {
5518 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5519 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5520 }
5521
5522 lType = lex->getType();
5523 rType = rex->getType();
5524
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005525 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005526 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005527
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005528 if (isRelational) {
5529 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005530 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005531 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005532 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005533 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005534 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005535
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005536 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005537 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005538 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005539
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005540 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005541 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005542 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005543 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005544
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005545 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5546 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005547 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005548 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005549 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005550 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005551 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005552
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005553 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005554 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5555 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005556 if (!isRelational &&
5557 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5558 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5559 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005560 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5561 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005562 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5563 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005564 Diag(Loc,
5565 isSFINAEContext()?
5566 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5567 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005568 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005569
5570 if (isSFINAEContext())
5571 return QualType();
5572
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005573 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005574 return ResultTy;
5575 }
5576 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005577 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5578 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5579 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5580 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5581 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5582 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005583 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005584 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005585 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005586 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005587 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005588 if (T.isNull()) {
5589 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5590 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5591 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005592 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005593 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005594 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005595 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005596 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005597 }
5598
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005599 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5600 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005601 return ResultTy;
5602 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005603 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5604 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5605 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5606 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5607 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5608 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5609 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5610 }
5611 } else if (!isRelational &&
5612 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5613 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5614 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5615 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5616 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5617 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5618 }
5619 } else {
5620 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005621 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005622 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005623 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005624 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005625 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005626 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005627 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005628
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005629 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005630 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005631 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005632 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005633 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5634 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005635 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5636 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005637 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5638 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005639 return ResultTy;
5640 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005641 if (LHSIsNull &&
5642 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5643 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005644 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5645 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005646 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5647 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005648 return ResultTy;
5649 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005650
5651 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005652 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005653 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5654 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005655 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5656 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5657 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5658 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5659 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5660 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5661 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5662 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005663 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005664 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005665 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005666 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005667 if (T.isNull()) {
5668 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005669 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005670 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005671 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005672 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005673 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005674 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005675 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005676 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005677
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005678 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5679 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005680 return ResultTy;
5681 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005682
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005683 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005684 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5685 return ResultTy;
5686 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005687
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005688 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005689 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005690 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5691 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005692
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005693 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005694 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005695 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005696 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005697 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005698 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005699 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005700 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005701 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005702 if (!isRelational
5703 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5704 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005705 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005706 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005707 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005708 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005709 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5710 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5711 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005712 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005713 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005714 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005715 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005716
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005717 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005718 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005719 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5720 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005721 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005722 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005723 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005724 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005725
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005726 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5727 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005728 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005729 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005730 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005731 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005732 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005733 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005734 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005735 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005736 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5737 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005738 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005739 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005740 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005741 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005742 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5743 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005744 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005745 bool isError = false;
5746 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5747 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5748 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005749 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005750 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005751 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005752 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5753 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5754 isError = true;
5755 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005756 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005757
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005758 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005759 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005760 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005761 if (isError)
5762 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005763 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005764
5765 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005766 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005767 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005768 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005769 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005770 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005771
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005772 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005773 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5774 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005775 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005776 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005777 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005778 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5779 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005780 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005781 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005782 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005783 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005784}
5785
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005786/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005787/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005788/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5789/// types.
5790QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005791 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005792 bool isRelational) {
5793 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5794 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005795 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005796 if (vType.isNull())
5797 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005798
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005799 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5800 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005801
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005802 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5803 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5804 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005805 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005806 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5807 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5808 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005809 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5810 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5811 << 0 // self-
5812 << 2 // "a constant"
5813 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005814 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005815
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005816 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005817 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5818 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005819 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005820 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005821
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005822 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5823 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5824 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005825 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005826 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005827
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005828 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005829 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005830 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005831 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005832 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005833 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5834
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005835 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005836 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005837 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5838}
5839
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005840inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005841 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005842 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5843 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5844 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5845 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5846
5847 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5848 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005849
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005850 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005852 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005853 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005854 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005855}
5856
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005857inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005858 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5859
5860 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5861 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5862 // is a constant.
5863 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005864 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005865 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005866 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5867 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5868 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5869 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5870 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5871 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5872 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5873 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5874 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005875 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5876 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005877 }
5878 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005879
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005880 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5881 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5882 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005883
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005884 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5885 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005886
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005887 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005888 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005889
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005890 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5891 // non-overloadable operands.
5892
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005893 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5894 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005895 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5896 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5897 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005898 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005899
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005900 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5901 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5902 // The result is a bool.
5903 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005904}
5905
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005906/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5907/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5908/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5909///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005910static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005911 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5912 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5913 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5914 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005915 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005916 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5917 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5918 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5919 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005920 }
5921 }
5922 return false;
5923}
5924
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005925/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5926/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5927static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005928 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005929 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005930 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005931 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5932 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005933 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5934 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005935
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005936 unsigned Diag = 0;
5937 bool NeedType = false;
5938 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005939 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005940 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005941 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5942 NeedType = true;
5943 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005944 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005945 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5946 NeedType = true;
5947 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005948 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005949 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5950 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005951 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5952 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005954 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5955 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005956 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5957 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005958 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5959 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005960 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005961 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005962 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005963 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005964 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5965 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005966 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005967 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5968 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005969 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5970 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5971 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005972 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5973 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5974 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005975 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5976 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5977 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005978 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005979
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005980 SourceRange Assign;
5981 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5982 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005983 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005984 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005985 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005986 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005987 return true;
5988}
5989
5990
5991
5992// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005993QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5994 SourceLocation Loc,
5995 QualType CompoundType) {
5996 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5997 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005998 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005999
6000 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6001 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006002 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006003 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006004 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006005 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006006 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6007 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6008 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6009 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6010 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6011 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6012 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6013 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6014 }
6015 }
6016
6017 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006018 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6019 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6020 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006021 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006022 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006023 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006024 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006025
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006026 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6027 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6028 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006029 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006030 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6031 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6032 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006033 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6034 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006035 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006036 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006037 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6038 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6039 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006040 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6041 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006042 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006043 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006044 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006045 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006046 }
6047 } else {
6048 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006049 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006050 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006051
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006052 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006053 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006054 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006055
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006056
6057 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6058 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6059 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6060 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6061 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6062 // check.
6063 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006064 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006065 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6066 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6067 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6068 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6069 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6070 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6071 }
6072
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006073 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6074 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006075 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006076 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6077 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006078 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006079 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006080 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006081}
6082
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006083// C99 6.5.17
6084QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006085 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6086
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006087 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006088 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6089 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6090 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006091
6092 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6093 // incomplete in C++).
6094
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006095 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006096}
6097
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006098/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6099/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006100QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006101 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006102 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6103 return Context.DependentTy;
6104
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006105 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6106 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006107
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006108 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6109 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6110 if (!isInc) {
6111 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6112 return QualType();
6113 }
6114 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6116 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006117 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006118 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6119 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006120
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006121 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006122 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006123 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6125 << Op->getSourceRange();
6126 return QualType();
6127 }
6128
6129 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006131 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006132 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6134 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6135 return QualType();
6136 }
6137
6138 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006139 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006140 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006141 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006142 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006143 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006144 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006145 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006146 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006147 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6148 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6149 return QualType();
6150 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006151 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006152 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6153 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006154 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006155 } else {
6156 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006157 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006158 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006159 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006160 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006161 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006162 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006163 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006164 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6165 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6166 // operand.
6167 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6168 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006169}
6170
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006171/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006172/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006173/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6174/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6175/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6176/// - &(x) => x
6177/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6178/// - &s.xx => s
6179/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6180/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6181/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6182/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006183static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006184 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006185 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006186 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006187 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006188 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6189 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6190 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006191 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006192 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006193 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006194 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006195 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006196 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6197 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006198 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6199 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6200 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6201 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6202 }
6203 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006204 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006205 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6206 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006207
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006208 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006209 case UO_Real:
6210 case UO_Imag:
6211 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006212 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6213 default:
6214 return 0;
6215 }
6216 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006217 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006218 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006219 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006220 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6221 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006222 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006223 default:
6224 return 0;
6225 }
6226}
6227
6228/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006229/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006230/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006231/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006232/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006233/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006234/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006235QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6236 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006237 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006238 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6239 return Context.OverloadTy;
6240
6241 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6242 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006243
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006244 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6245 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6246 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006247 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006248 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6249 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6250 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6251 }
6252 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6253 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6254 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006255 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006256 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006257
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006258 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006259 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6260 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6261 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6262 if (isSFINAEContext())
6263 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006264 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006265 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006266 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6267 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6268 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6269
6270 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6271 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6272 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6273 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6274 return QualType();
6275 }
6276 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6277 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6278
6279 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6280 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6281 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6282 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6283
6284 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6285 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6286 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6287 << op->getSourceRange();
6288 }
6289
6290 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6291 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6292 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006293 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006294 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006295 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006296 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006297 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6298 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006299 return QualType();
6300 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006301 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006302 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6303 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6304 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006305 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006306 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006307 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006308 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006309 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006310 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006311 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6312 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6313 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6314 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6315 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006316 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6317 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006318 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6319 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006320 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006321 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006322 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6323 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006324 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6325 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006326 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006327 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006328 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6329 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006330 return QualType();
6331 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006332 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006333 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006334 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006335 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006336 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6337 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006338 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006339 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006340 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6341 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006342 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006343 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6344 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6345 return QualType();
6346 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006347
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006348 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6349 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006350 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006351 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006352 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006353 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006354 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006355
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006356 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6357 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6358 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6359 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6360 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6361 }
6362
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006363 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006364 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6365 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006366 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006367}
6368
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006369/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006370QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006371 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6372 return Context.DependentTy;
6373
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006374 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006375 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6376 QualType Result;
6377
6378 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6379 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6380 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6381 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6382 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6383 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6384 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6385 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6386 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006387
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006388 if (Result.isNull()) {
6389 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6390 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6391 return QualType();
6392 }
6393
6394 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006395}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006396
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006397static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006398 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006399 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006400 switch (Kind) {
6401 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006402 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6403 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6404 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6405 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6406 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6407 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6408 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6409 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6410 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6411 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6412 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6413 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6414 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6415 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6416 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6417 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6418 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6419 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6420 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6421 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6422 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6423 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6424 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6425 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6426 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6427 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6428 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6429 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6430 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6431 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6432 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6433 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006434 }
6435 return Opc;
6436}
6437
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006438static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006439 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006440 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006441 switch (Kind) {
6442 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006443 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6444 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6445 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6446 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6447 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6448 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6449 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6450 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6451 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6452 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6453 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006454 }
6455 return Opc;
6456}
6457
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006458/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6459/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6460/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006461ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006462 unsigned Op,
6463 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006464 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006465 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006466 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6467 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6468 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006469
6470 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006471 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006472 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6473 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006474 case BO_PtrMemD:
6475 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006476 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006477 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006478 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006479 case BO_Mul:
6480 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006481 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006482 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006483 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006484 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006485 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6486 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006487 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006488 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6489 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006490 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006491 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6492 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006493 case BO_Shl:
6494 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006495 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6496 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006497 case BO_LE:
6498 case BO_LT:
6499 case BO_GE:
6500 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006501 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006502 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006503 case BO_EQ:
6504 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006505 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006506 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006507 case BO_And:
6508 case BO_Xor:
6509 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006510 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6511 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006512 case BO_LAnd:
6513 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006514 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006515 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006516 case BO_MulAssign:
6517 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006518 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006519 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006520 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6521 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6522 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006523 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006524 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006525 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6526 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6527 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6528 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006529 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006530 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006531 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6532 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6533 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006534 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006535 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006536 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6537 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6538 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006539 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006540 case BO_ShlAssign:
6541 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006542 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6543 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6544 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6545 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006546 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006547 case BO_AndAssign:
6548 case BO_XorAssign:
6549 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006550 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6551 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6552 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6553 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006554 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006555 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006556 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6557 break;
6558 }
6559 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006560 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006561 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006562 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006563 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6564 << ResultTy;
6565 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006566 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006567 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6568 else
6569 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006570 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6571 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006572}
6573
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006574/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6575/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006576static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6577 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006578 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6579 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6580 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006581 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006582 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6583
6584 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6585 return;
6586
6587 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6588 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6589 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006590 return;
6591 }
6592
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006593 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6594 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006595 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006596
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006597 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006598 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006599
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006600 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6601 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6602 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6603 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006604 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006605 return;
6606 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006607
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006608 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006609 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6610 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006611}
6612
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006613/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6614/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6615/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6616/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006617static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006618 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006619 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6620 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6621 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6622 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006623 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006624 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006625 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6626
6627 // Subs are not binary operators.
6628 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6629 return;
6630
6631 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6632 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006633 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6634 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006635 return;
6636
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006637 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006638 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006639 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006640 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6641 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006642 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006643 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006644 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6645 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6646 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6647 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006648 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006649 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006650 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006651 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6652 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006653 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006654 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006655 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6656 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6657 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6658 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006659}
6660
6661/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6662/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6663/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006664static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006665 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006666 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006667 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6668}
6669
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006670// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006671ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006672 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6673 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6674 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006675 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6676 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006677
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006678 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6679 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6680
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006681 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6682}
6683
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006684ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006685 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6686 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006687 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006688 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006689 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6690 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6691 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6692 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6693 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006694 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006695 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006696 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6697 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6698 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006699
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006700 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6701 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006702 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006703 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006704
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006705 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006706 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006707}
6708
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006709ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006710 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006711 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006712 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006713
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006714 QualType resultType;
6715 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716 case UO_PreInc:
6717 case UO_PreDec:
6718 case UO_PostInc:
6719 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006720 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006721 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6722 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6723 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6724 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006725 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006726 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006727 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006728 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006729 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006730 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006731 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006732 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006733 case UO_Plus:
6734 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006735 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6736 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006737 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6738 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006739 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6740 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006741 break;
6742 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6743 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6744 break;
6745 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006746 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006747 resultType->isPointerType())
6748 break;
6749
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006750 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6751 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006752 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006753 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6754 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006755 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6756 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006757 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6758 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6759 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006760 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006761 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006762 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006763 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6764 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006765 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006766 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006767 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006768 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006769 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006770 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6771 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006772 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006773 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6774 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006775 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006776 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6777 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006778 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006779 case UO_Real:
6780 case UO_Imag:
6781 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006782 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006783 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006784 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006785 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006786 }
6787 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006788 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006789
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006790 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006791}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006792
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006793ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006794 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6795 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006796 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006797 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006798 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6799 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6800 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6801 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006802 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006803 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006804 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6805 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6806 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006807
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006808 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006809 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006810
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006811 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006812}
6813
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006814// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006815ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006816 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6817 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006818}
6819
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006820/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006821ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006822 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6823 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006824 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006825 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006826
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006827 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6828 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006829 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006830 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006831
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006832 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006833 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6834 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006835}
6836
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006837ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006838Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006839 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006840 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6841 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6842
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006843 bool isFileScope
6844 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006845 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006846 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006847
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006848 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6849 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6850 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006851
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006852 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6853 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6854 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006855
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006856 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6857 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6858 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6859 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6860 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006861
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006862 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006863 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006864 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006865
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006866 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6867 // expressions are not lvalues.
6868
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006869 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006870}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006871
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006872ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006873 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006874 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6875 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006876 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6877 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006878 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006879 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006880
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006881 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6882 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6883 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006884 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006885 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6886 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6887
6888 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6889 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6890 if (!Dependent
6891 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6892 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6893 << TypeRange))
6894 return ExprError();
6895
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006896 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6897 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006898 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6899 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006900 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006901 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6902 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006903
6904 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6905 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6906 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6907 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6908 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6909 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6910 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6911 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6912 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6913 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6914 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6915 if(!AT)
6916 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6917 << CurrentType);
6918 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6919 } else
6920 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6921
6922 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6923 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6924 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6925 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6926 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6927 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6928 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6929 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6930
6931 // Record this array index.
6932 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6933 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6934 continue;
6935 }
6936
6937 // Offset of a field.
6938 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6939 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6940 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6941 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6942 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6943 continue;
6944 }
6945
6946 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6947 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6948 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6949 return ExprError();
6950
6951 // Look for the designated field.
6952 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6953 if (!RC)
6954 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6955 << CurrentType);
6956 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6957
6958 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6959 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6960 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6961 // (clause 9).
6962 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6963 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6964 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6965 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6966 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6967 << CurrentType))
6968 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6969 }
6970
6971 // Look for the field.
6972 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6973 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6974 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6975 if (!MemberDecl)
6976 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6977 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6978 OC.LocEnd));
6979
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006980 // C99 7.17p3:
6981 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6982 //
6983 // We diagnose this as an error.
6984 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6985 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6986 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6987 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6988 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6989 return ExprError();
6990 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006991
6992 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6993 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6994 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6995 do {
6996 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6997 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6998 }
6999
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007000 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7001 // the base class indirections.
7002 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7003 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007004 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007005 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7006 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7007 B != BEnd; ++B)
7008 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7009 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007010
7011 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007012 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7013 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7014 unsigned n = Path.size();
7015 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7016 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7017 } else {
7018 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7019 }
7020 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7021 }
7022
7023 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7024 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7025 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7026}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007027
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007028ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007029 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7030 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007031 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007032 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7033 unsigned NumComponents,
7034 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7035
7036 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7037 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7038 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7039 return ExprError();
7040
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007041 if (!ArgTInfo)
7042 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7043
7044 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7045 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007046}
7047
7048
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007049ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007050 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007051 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007052 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7053 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7054 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7055 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007056
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007057 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007058
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007059 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7060}
7061
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007062ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007063Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7064 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7065 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7066 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007067 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7068 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7069 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7070 return ExprError();
7071 }
7072
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007073 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007074 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007075}
7076
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007077
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007078ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007079 Expr *CondExpr,
7080 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007081 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007082 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7083
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007084 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007085 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007086 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007087 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007088 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007089 } else {
7090 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7091 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7092 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7093 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007094 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7095 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7096 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007097
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007098 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7099 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007100 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7101 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007102 }
7103
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007104 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007105 resType, RPLoc,
7106 resType->isDependentType(),
7107 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007108}
7109
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007110//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7111// Clang Extensions.
7112//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7113
7114/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007115void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007116 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7117 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7118 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007119 if (BlockScope)
7120 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7121 else
7122 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007123}
7124
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007125void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007126 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007127 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007128
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007129 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007131 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007132
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007133 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007134 QualType RetTy;
7135 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007136 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007137 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7140 } else {
7141 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007142 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007143 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007144
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007145 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007146
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007147 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7148 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7149 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007150 return;
7151 }
7152
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007153 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7154 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7155 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7156 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7157 return;
7158 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007159
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007160 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007161 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7162 // ^ * { ... }
7163 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007164 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7165 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007166
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007167 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007168 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007169 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7170 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7171 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7172 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007173 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7174 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7175 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7176 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7177 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007178 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007179 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007180
7181 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7182 // ^ fntype { ... }
7183 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7184 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7185 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7186 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7187 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7188 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7189 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007190 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007191 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007192 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007193
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007194 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7195 if (!Params.empty())
7196 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007197
7198 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007199 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007200
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007201 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007202 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7203 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7204 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7205 }
7206
7207 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7208 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007209 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007210 return;
7211
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007212 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7213 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7214
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007215 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007216 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7217 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7218
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007219 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007220 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7221 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7222 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7223
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007224 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007225 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007226 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007227}
7228
7229/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7230/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7231void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007232 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007233 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007234 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007235 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007236}
7237
7238/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7239/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007240ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007241 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007242 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7243 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7244 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007245
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007246 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007247
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007248 PopDeclContext();
7249
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007250 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007251 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7252 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007253
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007254 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007255 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007256
7257 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7258 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7259 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7260
7261 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7262 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7263
7264 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7265 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7266 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7267 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7268
7269 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7270 // preserve its sugar structure.
7271 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7272 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7273 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7274
7275 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7276 } else {
7277 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7278 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7279 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7280 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7281 FPT->isVariadic(),
7282 /*quals*/ 0,
7283 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7284 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7285 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7286 FPT->exception_begin(),
7287 Ext);
7288 }
7289
7290 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7291 } else {
7292 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7293 false, false, 0, 0,
7294 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7295 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007296
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007297 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007298 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7299 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007300 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007301
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007302 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007303 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007304 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007305
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007306 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007307
7308 bool Good = true;
7309 // Check goto/label use.
7310 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7311 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7312 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7313
7314 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7315 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7316 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7317 continue;
7318
7319 // Emit error.
7320 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7321 Good = false;
7322 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007323 if (!Good) {
7324 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007325 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007326 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007327
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007328 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7329 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7330
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007331 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007332 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7333 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007334 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007335
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007336 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007337 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007338}
7339
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007340ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007341 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007342 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007343 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7344 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007345 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007346}
7347
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007348ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007349 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007350 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007351 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007352
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007353 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007354
7355 // Get the va_list type
7356 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007357 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7358 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7359 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7360 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007361 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007362 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7363 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7364 } else {
7365 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7366 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007367 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007368 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007369 return ExprError();
7370 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007371
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007372 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7373 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007374 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7375 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007376 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007377 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007378
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007379 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007380 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007381
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007382 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7383 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007384}
7385
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007386ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007387 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7388 // pointers on the target.
7389 QualType Ty;
7390 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7391 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7392 else
7393 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7394
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007395 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007396}
7397
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007398static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007399 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007400 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7401 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007402
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007403 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7404 if (!PT)
7405 return;
7406
7407 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7408 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7409 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7410 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7411 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7412 return;
7413 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007414
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007415 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7416 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7417 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7418 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007419
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007420 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007421}
7422
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007423bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7424 SourceLocation Loc,
7425 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007426 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7427 bool *Complained) {
7428 if (Complained)
7429 *Complained = false;
7430
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007431 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7432 bool isInvalid = false;
7433 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007434 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007435
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007436 switch (ConvTy) {
7437 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7438 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007439 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007440 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7441 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007442 case IntToPointer:
7443 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7444 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007445 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007446 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007447 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7448 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007449 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7450 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7451 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007452 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7453 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7454 break;
7455 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007456 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7457 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7458 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7459 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7460 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7461 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7462 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7463 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7464 // C++ semantics.
7465 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7466 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7467 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007468 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7469 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007470 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007471 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007472 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007473 case IntToBlockPointer:
7474 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7475 break;
7476 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007477 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007478 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007479 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007480 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007481 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7482 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7483 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007484 case IncompatibleVectors:
7485 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7486 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007487 case Incompatible:
7488 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7489 isInvalid = true;
7490 break;
7491 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007492
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007493 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7494 switch (Action) {
7495 case AA_Assigning:
7496 case AA_Initializing:
7497 // The destination type comes first.
7498 FirstType = DstType;
7499 SecondType = SrcType;
7500 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007501
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007502 case AA_Returning:
7503 case AA_Passing:
7504 case AA_Converting:
7505 case AA_Sending:
7506 case AA_Casting:
7507 // The source type comes first.
7508 FirstType = SrcType;
7509 SecondType = DstType;
7510 break;
7511 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007512
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007513 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007514 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007515 if (Complained)
7516 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007517 return isInvalid;
7518}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007519
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007520bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007521 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7522 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7523 if (Result)
7524 *Result = ICEResult;
7525 return false;
7526 }
7527
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7529
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007530 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007531 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7532 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7533
7534 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7535 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7536 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7537 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7538 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7539 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7540 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007541
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007542 return true;
7543 }
7544
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007545 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7546 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007547
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007548 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7549 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7550 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007551
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007552 if (Result)
7553 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7554 return false;
7555}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007556
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007557void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007558Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007559 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7560 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007561}
7562
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007563void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007564Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7565 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7566 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7567 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007568
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007569 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7570 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7571 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7572 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7573 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007574 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007575 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7576 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7577 I != IEnd; ++I)
7578 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7579 }
7580
7581 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7582 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7583 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7584 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7585 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7586 I != IEnd; ++I)
7587 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7588 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007590
7591 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7592 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7593 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7594 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007595 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007596 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7597 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7598 ExprTemporaries.end());
7599
7600 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7601 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007602}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007603
7604/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7605///
7606/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7607/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7608/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7609/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7610///
7611/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7612///
7613/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7614void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7615 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007616
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007617 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007618 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007619
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007620 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7621 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7622 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7623 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007624 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007625 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007626 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007627 return;
7628 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007629
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007630 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7631 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007632
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007633 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7634 // an instantiation.
7635 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7636 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007637
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007638 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007639 case Unevaluated:
7640 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7641 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007642
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007643 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7644 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7645 // "used"; handle this below.
7646 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007647
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007648 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7649 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7650 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7651 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007652 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007653 return;
7654 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007655
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007656 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007657 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007658 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007659 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007660 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7661 return;
7662 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7663 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007664 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007665 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007666 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007667 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7668 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007669
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007670 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007671 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007672 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007673 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007674 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7675 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007676 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7677 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7678 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007679 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007680 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007681 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7682 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007683 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007684 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007685 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007686 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007687 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007688 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7689 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7690 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7691 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7692 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007693 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007694 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007695 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007696 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007697 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7698 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7699 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007700 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007701 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007702 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7703 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007704
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007705 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7706 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7707 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7708 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7709 Loc));
7710 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007711 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007712 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007713 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7714 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7715 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007716 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007717 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7718 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007719
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007720 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007721
7722 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7723 if (CurContext != Function)
7724 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007725
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007726 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007727 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007728
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007729 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007730 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007731 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007732 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7733 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7734 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7735 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7736 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7737 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007738 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007739 }
7740 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007741
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007742 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007743
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007744 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007745 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007746 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007747}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007748
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007749namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007750 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007751 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007752 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007753 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7754 Sema &S;
7755 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007756
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007757 public:
7758 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007759
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007760 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007761
7762 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7763 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007764 };
7765}
7766
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007767bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7768 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007769 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7770 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7771 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007772
7773 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007774}
7775
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007776bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007777 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7778 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7779 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007780 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7781 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007782 }
7783
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007784 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007785}
7786
7787void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7788 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007789 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007790}
7791
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007792/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7793/// of the program being compiled.
7794///
7795/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007796/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007797/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7798/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7799/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7800/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007801/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007802/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007804/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7805/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7806/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7807/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007808bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007809 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7810 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7811 case Unevaluated:
7812 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7813 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007814
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007815 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7816 Diag(Loc, PD);
7817 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007818
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007819 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7820 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7821 break;
7822 }
7823
7824 return false;
7825}
7826
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007827bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7828 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7829 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7830 return false;
7831
7832 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7833 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7834 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7835 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007836
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007837 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007838 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007839 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7840 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007841 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007842 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7843 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7844 return true;
7845
7846 return false;
7847}
7848
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007849// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7850// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7851void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7852 SourceLocation Loc;
7853
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007854 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7855
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007856 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7857 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007858 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007859 return;
7860
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007861 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7862 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7863 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7864 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7865
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007866 // self = [<foo> init...]
7867 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7868 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7869 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7870
7871 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7872 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7873 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7874 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7875 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007876
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007877 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7878 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7879 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7880 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7881 return;
7882
7883 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7884 } else {
7885 // Not an assignment.
7886 return;
7887 }
7888
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007889 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007890 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007891
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007892 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007893 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007894 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007895 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7896 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7897 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007898}
7899
7900bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7901 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7902
7903 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007904 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007905
7906 QualType T = E->getType();
7907
7908 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7909 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7910 return true;
7911 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7912 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7913 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7914 return true;
7915 }
7916 }
7917
7918 return false;
7919}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007920
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007921ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7922 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007923 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007924 return ExprError();
7925
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007926 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007927 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007928
7929 return Owned(Sub);
7930}